blob: c6d5c6590d869bc5af97ef7306177f3f1095f36e [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000381
382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000680/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
681/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
682/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000684 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
685 return false;
686
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
688 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
689 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
690 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
691 if (!BaseRT) return false;
692
693 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000695 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
696 return false;
697 }
698
699 return true;
700}
701
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000702/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
703/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
704static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000707 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
708 if (!DC) return true;
709
710 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
711 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
712
713 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
714 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
715
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000716 return false;
717}
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000718
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
720/// the prospective base classes.
721static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
722 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
723 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000724 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 return false;
726
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000727 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000728 if (!RD) return false;
729 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
730
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
732 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
733 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
734 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
735 if (!BaseRT) return false;
736
737 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000738 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
739 return false;
740 }
741
742 return true;
743}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000744
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745enum IMAKind {
746 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
747 IMA_Static,
748
749 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
750 IMA_Mixed,
751
752 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
753 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
754 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
757 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
758 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
759
760 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
761 IMA_Instance,
762
763 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
764 IMA_Unresolved,
765
766 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
767 /// context is not an instance method.
768 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
769
770 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
771 /// non-class context.
772 IMA_AnonymousMember,
773
774 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
775 /// context is not an instance method.
776 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
777
778 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
779 /// class.
780 IMA_Error_Unrelated
781};
782
783/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
784/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
785/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
786/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
787/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
788/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
789static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
790 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000791 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000792
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000793 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000795 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
796 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000797
798 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
799 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
800
801 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
802 bool hasNonInstance = false;
803 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
804 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000805 NamedDecl *D = *I;
806 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000807 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
808
809 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
810 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
811 // that's a special case.
812 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
813 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
814 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
815 }
816 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
817 }
818 else
819 hasNonInstance = true;
820 }
821
822 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
823 // member reference.
824 if (Classes.empty())
825 return IMA_Static;
826
827 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
828 // an implicit member reference.
829 if (isStaticContext)
830 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
831
832 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
833 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
834 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
835 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000836 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000837 Classes))
838 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
839
840 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
841}
842
843/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
844static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
845 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
846 const LookupResult &R) {
847 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
848 SourceRange Range(Loc);
849 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
850
851 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
852 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
853 if (MD->isStatic()) {
854 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
856 << Range << R.getLookupName();
857 return;
858 }
859 }
860
861 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
862 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
863 return;
864 }
865
866 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000867}
868
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
870///
871/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000872bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000873 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
875
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000876 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000877 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
879 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000880 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000881 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000882 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
883 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000884
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000885 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
886 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
887 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
888 // dependent name.
889 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
890 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000891 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
892 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
893
894 if (!R.empty()) {
895 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
896 R.suppressDiagnostics();
897
898 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
899 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
900 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
901 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
902
903 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
904 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
905 // Actually quite difficult!
906 if (isInstance)
907 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000908 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000909 else
910 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
911
912 // Do we really want to note all of these?
913 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
914 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
915
916 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
917 return false;
918 }
919 }
920 }
921
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000922 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000923 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000924 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000925 if (!R.empty()) {
926 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
927 if (SS.isEmpty())
928 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
929 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
930 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
931 else
932 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
933 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
934 << SS.getRange()
935 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
936 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
937 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
938 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
939 << ND->getDeclName();
940
941 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
942 return false;
943 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000944
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
947 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
948 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
949 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
950 // to recover well anyway.
951 if (SS.isEmpty())
952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
953 else
954 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
955 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
956 << SS.getRange();
957
958 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
959 return true;
960 }
961 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000962 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000963 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000964 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000965 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000966 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000967 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000968 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
969 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000970 return true;
971 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000972 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000973 }
974
975 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
976 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
977 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
978 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
979 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
980 << SS.getRange();
981 return true;
982 }
983
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000984 // Give up, we can't recover.
985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
986 return true;
987}
988
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000989Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000990 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000991 UnqualifiedId &Id,
992 bool HasTrailingLParen,
993 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
994 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
995 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
996
997 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +0000998 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +0000999
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001000 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001001
1002 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1003 DeclarationName Name;
1004 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1005 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001006 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1007 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001008
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001009 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001010
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001011 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1012 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001013 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1014 // (note: handled after lookup)
1015 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1016 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1017 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001018 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1019 // names a dependent type.
1020 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1021 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001022 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1023 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1024 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001025 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001026 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001027 TemplateArgs);
1028 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001029
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001030 // Perform the required lookup.
1031 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1032 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001033 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1034 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1035 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1036 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1037 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001038 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1039 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1040 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001041 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001042 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1043 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001044
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1046 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001047 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1048 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001049 if (E.isInvalid())
1050 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001051
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001052 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1053 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001054 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001055 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001056
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001057 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1058 return ExprError();
1059
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001060 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1061 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001062 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001063
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001064 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001065 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001066 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1067 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1068 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1069 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1070 }
1071
1072 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1073 // call, diagnose the problem.
1074 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001075 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001076 return ExprError();
1077
1078 assert(!R.empty() &&
1079 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001080
1081 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1082 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001083 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001084 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1085 R.clear();
1086 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1087 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1088 return move(E);
1089 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001090 }
1091 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001092
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1094 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1095
1096 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001097 // Warn about constructs like:
1098 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1099 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001100 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1101 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001102 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001103 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001104 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001105 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001106 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001107 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1108 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001109 break;
1110 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001111
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001112 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1113 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001114 }
1115 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001116 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001117 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1118 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1119 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1120 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1121 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1122 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001125
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001126 QualType T = Func->getType();
1127 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001128 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001129 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1130 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001131 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001132 }
1133 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001134
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001135 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1136 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1137 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1138 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1139 // class member access expression.
1140 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1141 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001142 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001144 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1145 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001146 }
1147
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 if (TemplateArgs)
1149 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001150
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1152}
1153
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001154/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1155Sema::OwningExprResult
1156Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1157 LookupResult &R,
1158 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1159 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1160 case IMA_Instance:
1161 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1162
1163 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1164 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1165 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1166 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1167
1168 case IMA_Mixed:
1169 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1170 case IMA_Unresolved:
1171 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1172
1173 case IMA_Static:
1174 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1175 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1176 if (TemplateArgs)
1177 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1178 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1179
1180 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1181 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1182 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1183 return ExprError();
1184 }
1185
1186 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1187 return ExprError();
1188}
1189
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001190/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1191/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1192/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1193/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001194Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001195Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001196 DeclarationName Name,
1197 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1198 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001199 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001200 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1201
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001202 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001203 return ExprError();
1204
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001205 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1206 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1207
1208 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1209 return ExprError();
1210
1211 if (R.empty()) {
1212 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1213 return ExprError();
1214 }
1215
1216 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1217}
1218
1219/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1220/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1221/// additional lookup.
1222///
1223/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1224/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1225///
1226/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1227Sema::OwningExprResult
1228Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001229 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001230 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001231 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001232
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001233 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1234 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1235 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1236 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1237 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1238
1239 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1240 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1241 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001242 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001243
1244 bool LookForIvars;
1245 if (Lookup.empty())
1246 LookForIvars = true;
1247 else if (IsClassMethod)
1248 LookForIvars = false;
1249 else
1250 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1251 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001252 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001254 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001255 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1256 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1257 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1258 if (IsClassMethod)
1259 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1260 << IV->getDeclName());
1261
1262 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1263 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1264 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1265 return ExprError();
1266
1267 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1268 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1269 return ExprError();
1270
1271 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1272 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1273 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1274 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1275
1276 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1277 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1278 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1279 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001280 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001281 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1282 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1283 SelfName, false, false);
1284 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1285 return Owned(new (Context)
1286 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1287 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1288 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001289 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001290 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001291 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001292 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1293 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1294 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1295 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1296 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1297 }
1298 }
1299
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001300 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1301 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1302 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1303 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1304 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1305 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1306 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1307 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1308 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1309 }
1310 }
1311 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1313 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001314}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001315
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001316/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1317///
1318/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1319///
1320/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1321/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1322/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1323/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1324///
1325/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1326/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1327/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1328/// the class declaring the member.
1329///
1330/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1331/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1332/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001333bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001334Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1335 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001336 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001337 NamedDecl *Member) {
1338 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1339 if (!RD)
1340 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001341
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001342 QualType DestRecordType;
1343 QualType DestType;
1344 QualType FromRecordType;
1345 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1346 bool PointerConversions = false;
1347 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1348 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001349
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001350 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1351 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1352 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1353 PointerConversions = true;
1354 } else {
1355 DestType = DestRecordType;
1356 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001357 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001358 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1359 if (Method->isStatic())
1360 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001361
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001362 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1363 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001364
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001365 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1366 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1367 PointerConversions = true;
1368 } else {
1369 FromRecordType = FromType;
1370 DestType = DestRecordType;
1371 }
1372 } else {
1373 // No conversion necessary.
1374 return false;
1375 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001376
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001377 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1378 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001379
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001380 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1381 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1382 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001383
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001384 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1385 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1386
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001387 bool isLvalue
1388 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1389
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001390 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001391 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001392 // class name.
1393 //
1394 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1395 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1396 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1397 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1398 //
1399 // class Base { public: int x; };
1400 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1401 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1402 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1403 //
1404 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1405 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1406 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1407 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001408 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001409 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1410 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1411 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1412
1413 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1414
1415 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1416 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1417 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1418 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001419 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001420 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001421 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001422 return true;
1423
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001424 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001425 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001426 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001427 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001428
1429 FromType = QType;
1430 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1431
1432 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1433 // we're done.
1434 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1435 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001436 }
1437 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001438
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001439 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001440
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001441 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1442 // down to the using declaration's type.
1443 //
1444 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1445 // class ever has member declarations.
1446 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1447 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1448 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1449 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1450
1451 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1452 // conversion is non-trivial.
1453 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1454 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001455 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001456 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001457 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001458 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001459
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001460 QualType UType = URecordType;
1461 if (PointerConversions)
1462 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001463 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001464 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001465 FromType = UType;
1466 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1467 }
1468
1469 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1470 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1471 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001472 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001473
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001474 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1475 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1476 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001477 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001478 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001479
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001480 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001481 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001482 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001483}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001484
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001485/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001486static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001487 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001488 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1489 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001490 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1491 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1492 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001493 if (SS.isSet()) {
1494 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1495 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001496 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001497
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001498 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001499 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001500}
1501
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001502/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1503/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1504/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1505/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001506Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001507Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1508 LookupResult &R,
1509 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1510 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001511 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1512
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001513 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001514
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001515 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1516 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001517 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001519 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001520 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001521 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001522
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001523 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1524 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001525 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1526 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1528 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001529 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1530 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1531 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1532 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001533 }
1534
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001535 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1536 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1537 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001538 SS,
1539 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1540 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001541}
1542
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001543bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001544 const LookupResult &R,
1545 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001546 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1547 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1548 return false;
1549
1550 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001551 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001552 return false;
1553
1554 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001555 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001556 return false;
1557
1558 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1559 // normal lookup:
1560 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1561 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1562
1563 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1564 // -- a declaration of a class member
1565 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1566 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001567 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001568 return false;
1569
1570 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1571 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1572 // using-declaration
1573 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1574 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1575 // turn off ADL anyway).
1576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1577 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1578 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1579 return false;
1580
1581 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1582 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1583 // template
1584 // And also for builtin functions.
1585 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1586 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1587
1588 // But also builtin functions.
1589 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1590 return false;
1591 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1592 return false;
1593 }
1594
1595 return true;
1596}
1597
1598
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001599/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1600/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1601/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1602/// will in fact be used.
1603static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1604 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1605 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1606 return true;
1607 }
1608
1609 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1610 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1611 return true;
1612 }
1613
1614 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1615 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1616 return true;
1617 }
1618
1619 return false;
1620}
1621
1622Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001624 LookupResult &R,
1625 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001626 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1627 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001628 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001629 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001630
1631 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1632 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1633 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001634 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1635 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001636 return ExprError();
1637
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001638 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1639 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1640 // we've picked a target.
1641 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1642
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643 bool Dependent
1644 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001645 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001646 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001647 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1648 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001650 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1651 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001652
1653 return Owned(ULE);
1654}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001655
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001656
1657/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1658Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001659Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001660 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1661 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001662 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1663 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001664
1665 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1666 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001667
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001668 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1669 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1670 // a template argument list.
1671 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1672 << Template << SS.getRange();
1673 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1674 return ExprError();
1675 }
1676
1677 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1678 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1679 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001680 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001681 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001682 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001683 return ExprError();
1684 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001685
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001686 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1687 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1688 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1689 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001690 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001691 return ExprError();
1692
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001693 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1694 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001695 return ExprError();
1696
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001697 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1698 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1699 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1700 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001701 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001702 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1703 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1704 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001705 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001706 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001707 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1708 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1709 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1710 return ExprError();
1711 }
1712
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001713 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001714 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1715 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1716 return ExprError();
1717 }
1718
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001719 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001720 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001721 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001722 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001723 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001724 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1725 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001726 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001727
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001728 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001729 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1730 ExprTy, Loc, false,
1731 constAdded);
1732 QualType T = VD->getType();
1733 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !T->isDependentType() &&
1734 !T->isReferenceType()) {
1735 Expr *E = new (Context)
1736 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1737 SourceLocation());
1738
1739 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001740 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
1741 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001742 SourceLocation(),
1743 Owned(E));
1744 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001745 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001746 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahaniand7c73382010-06-08 17:52:11 +00001747 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001748 }
1749 }
1750 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001751 }
1752 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1753 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001754
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001755 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001756}
1757
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001758Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1759 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001760 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001761
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001762 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001763 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001764 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1765 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1766 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001767 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001768
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001769 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1770 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001771
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001772 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1773 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001774 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001775 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001776 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001777
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001778 QualType ResTy;
1779 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1780 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1781 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001782 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001783
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001784 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001785 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001786 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1787 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001788 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001789}
1790
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001791Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001792 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001793 bool Invalid = false;
1794 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1795 if (Invalid)
1796 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001797
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001798 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1799 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001800 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001801 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001802
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001803 QualType Ty;
1804 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1805 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1806 else if (Literal.isWide())
1807 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001808 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1809 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001810 else
1811 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001812
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001813 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1814 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001815 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001816}
1817
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1819 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001820 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1821 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001822 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001823 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001824 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001825 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001826 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001827
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001828 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001829 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1830 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001831 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001832
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001833 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001834 bool Invalid = false;
1835 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1836 if (Invalid)
1837 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001838
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001839 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001840 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1841 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001842 return ExprError();
1843
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001844 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001845
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001846 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001847 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001848 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001849 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001850 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001851 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001852 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001853 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001854
1855 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1856
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001857 using llvm::APFloat;
1858 APFloat Val(Format);
1859
1860 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001861
1862 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1863 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1864 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1865 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001866 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001867 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001868 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001869 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001870 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1871 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001872 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001873 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1874 }
1875
1876 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1877 << Ty
1878 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1879 }
1880
1881 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001882 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001883
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001884 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001885 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001886 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001887 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001888
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001889 // long long is a C99 feature.
1890 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001891 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001892 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1893
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001894 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001895 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001896
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001897 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1898 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1899 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001900 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1901 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001902 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001903 } else {
1904 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1905 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001906
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001907 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1908 // be an unsigned int.
1909 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1910
1911 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001912 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001913 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1914 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001915 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001917 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1918 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1919 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1920 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001921 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001922 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001923 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001924 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001925 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001926 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001928 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001929 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001930 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001932 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1933 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1934 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1935 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001936 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001937 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001938 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001939 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001940 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001941 }
1942
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001943 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001944 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001945 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001947 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1948 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1949 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1950 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001951 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001952 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001953 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001954 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001955 }
1956 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001958 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1959 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001960 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001961 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001962 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001963 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001964 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001966 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1967 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001968 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001969 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001970 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001972 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1973 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001974 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001975 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976
1977 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001978}
1979
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001980Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
1981 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00001982 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001983 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001984 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001985}
1986
1987/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
1988/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001989bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00001990 SourceLocation OpLoc,
1991 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
1992 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00001993 if (exprType->isDependentType())
1994 return false;
1995
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001996 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
1997 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
1998 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
1999 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2000 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2001 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2002
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002003 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002004 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002005 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002006 if (isSizeof)
2007 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2008 return false;
2009 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002010
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002011 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002012 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2014 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002015 return false;
2016 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002017
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002018 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002019 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2020 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002021 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002022
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002023 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002024 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002025 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002026 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2027 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002028 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002029
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002030 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2031 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2032 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2033 return true;
2034 }
2035
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002036 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002037}
2038
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002039bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2040 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2041 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002042
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002043 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002044 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2045 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002046
2047 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2048 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2049 return false;
2050
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002051 if (E->getBitField()) {
2052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2053 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002054 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002055
2056 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2057 // bit-field.
2058 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002059 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002060 return false;
2061
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2063}
2064
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002065/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002067Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002068 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002069 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002070 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002071 return ExprError();
2072
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002073 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002074
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002075 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2076 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2077 return ExprError();
2078
2079 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002080 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002081 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2082 R.getEnd()));
2083}
2084
2085/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2086/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002087Action::OwningExprResult
2088Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002089 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2090 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2091 bool isInvalid = false;
2092 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2093 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2094 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2095 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002096 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002097 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2098 isInvalid = true;
2099 } else {
2100 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2101 }
2102
2103 if (isInvalid)
2104 return ExprError();
2105
2106 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2107 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2108 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2109 R.getEnd()));
2110}
2111
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002112/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2113/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2114/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002115Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002116Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2117 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002118 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002119 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002120
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002121 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002122 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2123 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2124 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002125 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002126
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002127 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2128 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2129 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2130
2131 if (Result.isInvalid())
2132 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2133
2134 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002135}
2136
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002137QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002138 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2139 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002140
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002141 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002142 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002143 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002144
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002145 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2146 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2147 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002149 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002150 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2151 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002152 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002153}
2154
2155
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002156
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002157Action::OwningExprResult
2158Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2159 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002160 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2161 switch (Kind) {
2162 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2163 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2164 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2165 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002166
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002167 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002168}
2169
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002170Action::OwningExprResult
2171Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2172 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002173 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2174 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2175
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002176 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2177 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002180 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2181 Base.release();
2182 Idx.release();
2183 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2184 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2185 }
2186
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002187 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002188 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002189 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2190 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2191 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002192 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002193 }
2194
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002195 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2196}
2197
2198
2199Action::OwningExprResult
2200Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2201 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2202 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2203 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2204
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002205 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002206 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2207 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2208 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002209
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002210 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002211
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002212 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002213 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002214 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002215 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002216 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2217 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002218 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2219 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2220 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2221 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002222 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002223 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2224 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002225 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002226 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002227 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2229 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002230 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002231 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002232 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002233 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2234 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2235 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002237 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002238 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2239 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2240 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2241 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002242 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002243 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002244 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002245
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2247 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002248 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2249 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002250 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002251 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2252 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2253 // force the promotion here.
2254 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2255 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002256 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2257 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002258 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2259
2260 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2261 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002262 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002263 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2264 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2265 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2266 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002267 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2268 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2270
2271 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2272 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002273 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002274 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002275 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2276 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002277 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002278 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002279 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2280 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002281 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2282 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002283
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002284 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002285 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2286 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002287 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2288
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002289 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002290 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2291 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002292 // incomplete types are not object types.
2293 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2294 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2295 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2296 return ExprError();
2297 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002298
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002299 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002300 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002301 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2302 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002303 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002305 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002306 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002307 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2308 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2309 return ExprError();
2310 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002312 Base.release();
2313 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002314 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002315 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002316}
2317
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002318QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002319CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002321 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002322 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2323 // see FIXME there.
2324 //
2325 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2326 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002327 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002328
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002329 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002330 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002331
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002332 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002333 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2334 // to be selected.
2335 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002336
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002337 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2338 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002339 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002340
2341 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2342 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002343 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002344 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2345 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002346 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002347 do
2348 compStr++;
2349 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002350 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002351 do
2352 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002353 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002354 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002355
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002356 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002357 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2358 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002359 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2360 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002361 return QualType();
2362 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002363
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002364 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2365 // operates on.
2366 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002367 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002368
2369 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002370 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002371
2372 while (*compStr) {
2373 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2374 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2375 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2376 return QualType();
2377 }
2378 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002379 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002380
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002381 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002382 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002383 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002384 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002385 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002386 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002387 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002388 if (HexSwizzle)
2389 CompSize--;
2390
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002391 if (CompSize == 1)
2392 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002393
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002394 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002395 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002396 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2397 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2398 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2399 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002400 }
2401 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002402}
2403
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002404static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002405 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002406 const Selector &Sel,
2407 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002408
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002409 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002410 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002411 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002412 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002413
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002414 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2415 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002416 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002417 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002418 return D;
2419 }
2420 return 0;
2421}
2422
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002423static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002424 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002425 const Selector &Sel,
2426 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002427 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2428 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002429 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002430 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002431 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002432 GDecl = PD;
2433 break;
2434 }
2435 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002436 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002437 GDecl = OMD;
2438 break;
2439 }
2440 }
2441 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002442 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002443 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2444 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002445 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002446 if (GDecl)
2447 return GDecl;
2448 }
2449 }
2450 return GDecl;
2451}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002452
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002453Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002454Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2455 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002456 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2457 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2458 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2459 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2460 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2461
2462 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2463 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2464 //
2465 // T* t;
2466 // t.f;
2467 //
2468 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2469 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2470 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2471 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002472 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002473 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2474 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002475 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002476 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002477 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002478 return ExprError();
2479 }
2480 }
2481
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002482 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002483 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002484
2485 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2486 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002487 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002488 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2489 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2490 SS.getRange(),
2491 FirstQualifierInScope,
2492 Name, NameLoc,
2493 TemplateArgs));
2494}
2495
2496/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2497/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2498/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2499static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2500 Expr *BaseExpr,
2501 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002502 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002503 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002504 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2505 // diagnostics.
2506 if (!BaseExpr)
2507 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002508
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002509 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2510 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002511}
2512
2513// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2514// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2515// type. The restriction here is:
2516//
2517// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2518// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2519// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2520//
2521// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2522// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2523// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2524// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2525bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2526 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002527 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002528 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002529 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2530 if (!BaseRT) {
2531 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2532 // dependent.
2533 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2534 return false;
2535 }
2536 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002537
2538 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002539 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2540 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002541 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002542 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002543
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002544 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2545 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2546 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2547 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2548
2549 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2550 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2551
2552 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2553 return false;
2554 }
2555
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002556 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002557 return true;
2558}
2559
2560static bool
2561LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2562 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002563 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2564 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002565 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2566 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002567 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002568 << BaseRange))
2569 return true;
2570
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002571 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2572 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2573 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2574
2575 bool MOUS;
2576 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2577 return false;
2578 }
2579
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002580 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2581 if (SS.isSet()) {
2582 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2583 // nested-name-specifier.
2584 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2585
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002586 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002587 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2588 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2589 return true;
2590 }
2591
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002592 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002593
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002594 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2595 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2596 << DC << SS.getRange();
2597 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598 }
2599 }
2600
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002601 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2602 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002603
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002604 if (!R.empty())
2605 return false;
2606
2607 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2608 // for typos.
2609 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002610 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002611 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002612 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2613 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2614 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002615 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2616 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002617 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2618 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2619 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002620 return false;
2621 } else {
2622 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002623 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002624 }
2625
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002626 return false;
2627}
2628
2629Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002630Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002631 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002632 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002633 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2634 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2635 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2636 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2637
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002638 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2639 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002640 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002641 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2642 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2643 Name, NameLoc,
2644 TemplateArgs);
2645
2646 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002647
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002648 // Implicit member accesses.
2649 if (!Base) {
2650 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2651 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2652 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2653 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002654 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002655 return ExprError();
2656
2657 // Explicit member accesses.
2658 } else {
2659 OwningExprResult Result =
2660 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002661 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002662
2663 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2664 Owned(Base);
2665 return ExprError();
2666 }
2667
2668 if (Result.get())
2669 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002670
2671 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2672 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673 }
2674
Sebastian Redl0aa866f2010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002675 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002676 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2677 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002678}
2679
2680Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002681Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2682 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2683 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002684 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002685 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002686 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2687 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002688 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002689 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002690 if (IsArrow) {
2691 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2692 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2693 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002694 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002695
2696 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2697 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2698 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2699 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2700
2701 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002702 return ExprError();
2703
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002704 if (R.empty()) {
2705 // Rederive where we looked up.
2706 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2707 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2708 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002709
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002710 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711 << MemberName << DC
2712 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002713 return ExprError();
2714 }
2715
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002716 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2717 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2718 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2719 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2720 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2721 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2722 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2723 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2724 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2725 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002726 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002727 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728 return ExprError();
2729
2730 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2731 // result.
2732 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002733 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002734 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002735 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002736 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002737
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002738 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2739 // pick a member.
2740 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2741
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002742 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2743 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2744 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002745 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2746 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002747 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2748 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002749 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002750
2751 return Owned(MemExpr);
2752 }
2753
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002754 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002755 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2757
2758 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2759
2760 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2761 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2762 // error cases.
2763 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2764 return ExprError();
2765
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002766 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2767 if (!BaseExpr) {
2768 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002769 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002770 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2771
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002772 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2773 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2774 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2775 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002776 }
2777
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002778 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2779 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2780 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2781 // explicitly qualified.
2782 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2783 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2784 }
2785
2786 // Check the use of this member.
2787 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2788 Owned(BaseExpr);
2789 return ExprError();
2790 }
2791
2792 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2793 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2794 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002795 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2796 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002797 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2798 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2799
2800 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2801 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2802 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2803 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2804 else {
2805 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2806 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2807 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2808
2809 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2810 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2811
2812 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2813 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2814 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2815 }
2816
2817 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002818 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002819 return ExprError();
2820 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002821 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822 }
2823
2824 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2825 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2826 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002827 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002828 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2829 }
2830
2831 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2832 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2833 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002834 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002835 MemberFn->getType()));
2836 }
2837
2838 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2839 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2840 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002841 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002842 }
2843
2844 Owned(BaseExpr);
2845
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002846 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002847 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002848 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2849 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2850 else
2851 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2852 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002853
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002854 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2855 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002856 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002857 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002858}
2859
2860/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2861/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2862/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2863/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2864/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2865/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2866/// an ordinary member expression.
2867///
2868/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2869/// fixed for ObjC++.
2870Sema::OwningExprResult
2871Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002872 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002873 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002874 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002875 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002876
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002877 // Perform default conversions.
2878 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002879
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002880 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002881 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2882
2883 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2884 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002885
2886 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002887 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002888 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2889 // call, and continue on.
2890 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2891 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2892 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2893 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2894 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2896 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002897 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2898 ->isRecordType()))) {
2899 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2900 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2901 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002902 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002903
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002904 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002905 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002906 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00002907 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002908 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002909 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002910
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002911 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2912 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2913 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2914 }
2915 }
2916 }
2917
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002918 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2919 // use that.
2920 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002921 if (IsArrow) {
2922 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2923 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2924 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002925 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002926 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002927 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2928 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002929 }
2930 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002931 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2932 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2933 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2934 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002935 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002936 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002937 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002938
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002939 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2940 // use that.
2941 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2942 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2943 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2944 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2945 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2946 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2947 }
2948 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002949
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002950 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002951
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002952 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002953 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002954 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2955 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2956 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2957 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2958 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2959 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2960 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2961 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2962 // Check the use of this method.
2963 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2964 return ExprError();
2965 }
2966 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2967 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2968 Selector SetterSel =
2969 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2970 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2971 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2972 if (!Setter) {
2973 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2974 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002975 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002976 }
2977 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2978 if (!Setter)
2979 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002980
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002981 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2982 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002983
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002984 if (Getter || Setter) {
2985 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002986
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002987 if (Getter)
2988 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2989 else
2990 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
2991 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
2992 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002993 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002994 PType,
2995 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
2996 }
2997 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
2998 << MemberName << BaseType);
2999 }
3000 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003001
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003002 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3003 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3004 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003005 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003006 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003007
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003008 if (IsArrow) {
3009 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003010 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003011 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3012 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003013 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3014 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3015 // struct MyRecord foo;
3016 // foo->bar
3017 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3018 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3019 // by now.
3020 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3021 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003022 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003023 IsArrow = false;
3024 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003025 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3026 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3027 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003028 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003029 } else {
3030 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3031 // type *foo;
3032 // foo.bar
3033 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3034 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3035 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3036 // the appropriate pointer type
3037 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3038 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3039 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3040 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3041 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003042 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003043 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3044 IsArrow = true;
3045 }
3046 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003047 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003048
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003049 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003050 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003051 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003052 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003053 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003054 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003055 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003056
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003057 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3058 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003059 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003060 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003061 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003062 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3063 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3064 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3065 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003066 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3067
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003068 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003069 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003070
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003071 if (!IV) {
3072 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3073 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3074 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003075 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003076 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003077 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003078 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3079 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003080 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3081 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003082 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003083 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003084 } else {
3085 Res.clear();
3086 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003087 }
3088 }
3089
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003090 if (IV) {
3091 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3092 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3093 // error cases.
3094 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3095 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003096
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003097 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3098 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3099 return ExprError();
3100 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3101 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3102 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3103 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3104 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3105 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3106 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3107 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3108 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3109 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3110 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3111 // AST for a function decl.
3112 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003113 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003114 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3115 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3116 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3117 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3118 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3119 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003120
3121 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3122 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003123 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003125 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003126 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3127 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003128 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003129 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003130 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003131
3132 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3133 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003134 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003135 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003136 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003137 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003138 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003139 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003140 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003141 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003142 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3143 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003144 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003145 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003146
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003147 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003148 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003149 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3150 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3151 // Check the use of this declaration
3152 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3153 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003154
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003155 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3156 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3157 }
3158 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3159 // Check the use of this method.
3160 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3161 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003162
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003163 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003164 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3165 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3166 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003167 }
3168 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003169
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003170 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003171 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003172 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003173
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003174 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3175 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003176 if (!IsArrow)
3177 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3178 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003179 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003180
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003181 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003182 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003183 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3184 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003185 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003186 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003187 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003188
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003189 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003190 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003191 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003192 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3193 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003194 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003195 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003196 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003197 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003198
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003199 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3200 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3201
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003202 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003203}
3204
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003205/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3206/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3207/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3208/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3209/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3210///
3211/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3212/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3213/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3214/// only be called
3215/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3216/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3217/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3218Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3219 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3220 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003221 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003222 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3223 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3224 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3225 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3226 return ExprError();
3227
3228 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3229
3230 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3231 DeclarationName Name;
3232 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3233 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3234 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3235 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3236
3237 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3238
3239 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3240 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3241 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3242
3243 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3244 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3245
3246 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3247 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003248 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3249 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003250 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003251 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3252 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3253 Name, NameLoc,
3254 TemplateArgs);
3255 } else {
3256 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003257 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3258 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003259
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003260 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3261 Owned(Base);
3262 return ExprError();
3263 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003264
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003265 if (Result.get()) {
3266 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3267 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3268 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3269 // call now.
3270 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3271 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
3272 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003273
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003274 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003275 }
3276
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003277 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003278 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3279 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003280 }
3281
3282 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003283}
3284
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003285Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3286 FunctionDecl *FD,
3287 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3288 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3289 Diag (CallLoc,
3290 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3291 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003292 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003293 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3294 } else {
3295 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3296 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3297
3298 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003299 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3300 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003301
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003302 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3303 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregord6350ae2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003304 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003305
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003306 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003308 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003309
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003310 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3311 InitializedEntity Entity
3312 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3313 InitializationKind Kind
3314 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3315 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3316 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3317
3318 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003319 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003320 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3321 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003322 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003323
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003324 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003325 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003326 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003327 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003328
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003329 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3330 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3331 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003332 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3333 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003334 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3335 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003336 }
3337
3338 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003339 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003340}
3341
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003342/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3343/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3344/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3345/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3346/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3347/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003348bool
3349Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003350 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003351 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003352 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3353 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003354 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003355 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3356 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003357 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003358
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003359 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3360 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3361 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3362 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3363 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003364 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003365 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003366 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003367 }
3368
3369 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3370 // them.
3371 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3372 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3373 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3374 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003375 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003376 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003377 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3378 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3379 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003380 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003381 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003382 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003383 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003384 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003385 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003386 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3387 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3388 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3389 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3390 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003391 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003392 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003393 if (Invalid)
3394 return true;
3395 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3396 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3397 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003398
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003399 return false;
3400}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003401
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003402bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3403 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3404 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3405 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3406 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3407 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003408 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003409 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3410 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3411 bool Invalid = false;
3412 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3413 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3414 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3415 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003416 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003417 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003418 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003419
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003420 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003421 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3422 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003423
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003424 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3425 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003426 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003427 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003428 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003429
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003430 // Pass the argument
3431 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3432 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3433 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003434
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003435
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003436 InitializedEntity Entity =
3437 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3438 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3439 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3440 SourceLocation(),
3441 Owned(Arg));
3442 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3443 return true;
3444
3445 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003446 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003447 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003448
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003449 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003450 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003451 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3452 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003453
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003454 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003455 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003456 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003458
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003459 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003460 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003461 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003462 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003463 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003464 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003465 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003466 }
3467 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003468 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003469}
3470
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003471/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003472/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3473/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003474Action::OwningExprResult
3475Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3476 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003477 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003478 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003479
3480 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3481 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003482
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003483 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003484 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003485 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003486
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003488 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3489 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3490 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3491 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3492 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003493 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003494 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3495 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003496
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003497 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3498 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003499
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003500 NumArgs = 0;
3501 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003502
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003503 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3504 RParenLoc));
3505 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003506
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003507 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003508 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003509 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3510 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003511 bool Dependent = false;
3512 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3513 Dependent = true;
3514 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3515 Dependent = true;
3516
3517 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003518 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003519 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3520
3521 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3522 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3523 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3524 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3525
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003526 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3527
3528 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3529 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3530 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3531 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3532 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3533 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3534 // method template.
3535 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003536 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3537 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003538 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003539
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003540 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3541 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003542 }
3543
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003544 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003545 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003546 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003547 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003548 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3549 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003550 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003551
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003552 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003553 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003554 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3555 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003556 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3557 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003558 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003559
3560 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3561 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003562 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3563 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003564
3565 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3566 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003567 TheCall.get(), 0))
3568 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003569
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003570 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003571 RParenLoc))
3572 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003573
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003574 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3575 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003576 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003577 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3578 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003579 }
3580 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003581 }
3582
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003583 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003584 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003585 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003586
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003587 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003588 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3589 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003590 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003591 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003592 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003593
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003594 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3595 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3596 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3597
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003598 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3599}
3600
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003601/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3602/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003603/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3604/// block-pointer type.
3605///
3606/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3607Sema::OwningExprResult
3608Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3609 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3610 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3611 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3612 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3613
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003614 // Promote the function operand.
3615 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3616
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003617 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3618 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003619 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3620 Args, NumArgs,
3621 Context.BoolTy,
3622 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003623
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003624 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3625 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3626 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3627 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003628 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003629 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003630 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3631 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003632 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003633 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003634 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003635 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003636 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003637 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003638 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3639 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3640
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003641 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003642 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003643 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3644 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003645 return ExprError();
3646
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003647 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003648 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003649
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003650 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003651 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003652 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003653 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003654 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003655 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003656
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003657 if (FDecl) {
3658 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3659 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3660 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6fb0aee2009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003661 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003662 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003663 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003664 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3665 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3666 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3667 }
3668 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003669 }
3670
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003671 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003672 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3673 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3674 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003675 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3676 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003677 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3678 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003679 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003680 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003681 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003682 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003683
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003684 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3685 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003686 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3687 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003688
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003689 // Check for sentinels
3690 if (NDecl)
3691 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003692
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003693 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003694 if (FDecl) {
3695 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3696 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003697
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003698 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003699 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3700 } else if (NDecl) {
3701 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3702 return ExprError();
3703 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003704
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003705 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003706}
3707
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003708Action::OwningExprResult
3709Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3710 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003711 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003712 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003713 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003714
3715 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3716 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3717 if (!TInfo)
3718 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3719
3720 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3721}
3722
3723Action::OwningExprResult
3724Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3725 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3726 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003727 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003728
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003729 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003730 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003731 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3732 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003733 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3734 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003735 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003736 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003737 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003738 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003739
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003740 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003741 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003742 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003743 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003744 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003745 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3746 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3747 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3748 &literalType);
3749 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003750 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003751 InitExpr.release();
3752 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003753
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003754 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003755 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003756 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003757 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003758 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003759
3760 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003761
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003762 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003763 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003764}
3765
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003766Action::OwningExprResult
3767Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003768 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3769 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3770 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003771
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003772 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003773 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003774
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003775 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3776 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003777 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003778 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003779}
3780
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003781static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3782 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003783 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003784 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3785
3786 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3787 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003788 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3789 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003790 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003791 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3792 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3793 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003794
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003795 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3796 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3797 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3798 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3799 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3800 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3801 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3802 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003803
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003804 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3805 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3806 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3807 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3808 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3809 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003810
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003811 // FIXME: Assert here.
3812 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3813 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3814}
3815
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003816/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003817bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003818 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003819 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003820 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003821 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003822 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3823 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003824
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003825 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003826
3827 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3828 // type needs to be scalar.
3829 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3830 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003831 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3832 return false;
3833 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003834
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003835 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003836 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003837 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3838 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003839 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003840 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3841 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003842 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003843 return false;
3844 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003845
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003846 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003847 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003848 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003849 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003850 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003851 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003852 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003853 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003854 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3855 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3856 break;
3857 }
3858 }
3859 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3860 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3861 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003862 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003863 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003864 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003865
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003866 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3867 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3868 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3869 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003870
3871 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003872 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003873 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3874 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003875 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003876 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003877
3878 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003879 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003880
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003881 if (castType->isVectorType())
3882 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3883 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3884 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3885
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003886 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3887 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003888
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003889 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003890 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003891 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003892 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003893 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3894 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3895 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3896 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003897 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003898 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3899 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3900 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003901 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003902
3903 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003904 return false;
3905}
3906
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003907bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3908 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003909 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003910
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003911 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003912 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003913 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003914 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003915 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003916 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003917 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003918 } else
3919 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003920 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003921 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003922
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003923 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003924 return false;
3925}
3926
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003927bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003928 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003929 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003930
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003931 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003932
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003933 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3934 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003935 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3936 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3937 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3938 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003939 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003940 return false;
3941 }
3942
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003943 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003944 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3945 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003946 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3947 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3948 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3949 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003950
3951 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3952 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3953 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003954
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003955 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003956 return false;
3957}
3958
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003959Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003960Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003961 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3962 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3963 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003964
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003965 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3966 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3967 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003968 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003969
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003970 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003971 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003972 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003973 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3974 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003975
3976 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
3977}
3978
3979Action::OwningExprResult
3980Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
3981 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3982 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
3983
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003984 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003985 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003986 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003987 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003988 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00003989
Douglas Gregord6e44a32010-04-16 22:09:46 +00003990 Op.release();
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003991 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00003992 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssoncdb61972009-08-07 22:21:05 +00003993 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003994}
3995
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003996/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
3997/// of comma binary operators.
3998Action::OwningExprResult
3999Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4000 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4001 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4002 if (!E)
4003 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004004
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004005 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004006
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004007 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4008 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4009 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004010
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004011 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4012}
4013
4014Action::OwningExprResult
4015Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4016 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004017 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004018 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004019 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004020
4021 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004022 // then handle it as such.
4023 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4024 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4025 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4026 return ExprError();
4027 }
4028
4029 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4030 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4031 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4032
4033 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4034 // braces instead of the original commas.
4035 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004036 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4037 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004038 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4039 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004040 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004041 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004042 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004043 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4044 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004045 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004046 }
4047}
4048
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004049Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004050 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004051 MultiExprArg Val,
4052 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004053 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4054 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004055 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4056 Expr *expr;
4057 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4058 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4059 else
4060 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004061 return Owned(expr);
4062}
4063
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004064/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4065/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004066/// C99 6.5.15
4067QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4068 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004069 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4070 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4071 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4072
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004073 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4074 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4075 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4076 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4077 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4078 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004079
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004080 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004081 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4082 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4083 << CondTy;
4084 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004085 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004086
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004087 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004088 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4089 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004090
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004091 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4092 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004093 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4094 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4095 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004096 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004097
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004098 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4099 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004100 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4101 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004102 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004103 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004104 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004105 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004106 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004107 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004108
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004109 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004110 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004111 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4112 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4113 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4114 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4115 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4116 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4117 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004118 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4119 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004120 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004121 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004122 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4123 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004124 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004125 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004126 // promote the null to a pointer.
4127 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004128 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004129 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004130 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004131 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004132 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004133 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004134 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004135
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004136 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4137 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4138 QuestionLoc);
4139 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4140 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004141
4142
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004143 // Handle block pointer types.
4144 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4145 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4146 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4147 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004148 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4149 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004150 return destType;
4151 }
4152 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004153 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004154 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004155 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004156 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4157 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4158 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004159 return LHSTy;
4160 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004161 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004162 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4163 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004164
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004165 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4166 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004167 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004168 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004169 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4170 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4171 // to get a consistent AST.
4172 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004173 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4174 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004175 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004176 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004177 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004178 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4179 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004180 return LHSTy;
4181 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004182
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004183 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4184 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4185 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004186 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4187 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004188
4189 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4190 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4191 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004192 QualType destPointee
4193 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004194 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004195 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4196 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4197 // Promote to void*.
4198 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004199 return destType;
4200 }
4201 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004202 QualType destPointee
4203 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004204 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004205 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004206 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004207 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004208 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004209 return destType;
4210 }
4211
4212 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4213 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4214 return LHSTy;
4215 }
4216 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4217 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4218 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4219 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4220 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4221 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4222 // to get a consistent AST.
4223 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004224 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4225 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004226 return incompatTy;
4227 }
4228 // The pointer types are compatible.
4229 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4230 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4231 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4232 // type.
4233 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4234 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004235 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4236 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004237 return LHSTy;
4238 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004239
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004240 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4241 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4242 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4243 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004244 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004245 return RHSTy;
4246 }
4247 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4248 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4249 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004250 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004251 return LHSTy;
4252 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004253
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004254 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004255 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4256 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004257 return QualType();
4258}
4259
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004260/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4261/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4262QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4263 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4264 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4265 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004266
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004267 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4268 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4269 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4270 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4271 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4272 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4273 return LHSTy;
4274 }
4275 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4276 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4277 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4278 return RHSTy;
4279 }
4280 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4281 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4282 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4283 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4284 return LHSTy;
4285 }
4286 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4287 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4288 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4289 return RHSTy;
4290 }
4291 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4292 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4293 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4294 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4295 return LHSTy;
4296 }
4297 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4298 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4299 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4300 return RHSTy;
4301 }
4302 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4303 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004304
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004305 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4306 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4307 return LHSTy;
4308 }
4309 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4310 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4311 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004312
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004313 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4314 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4315 // type. This allows
4316 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4317 // where B is a subclass of A.
4318 //
4319 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4320 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4321 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4322 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004323
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004324 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4325 // It could return the composite type.
4326 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4327 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4328 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4329 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4330 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4331 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4332 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4333 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4334 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4335 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4336 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4337 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4338 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4339 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004340 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004341 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4342 ;
4343 else {
4344 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4345 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4346 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4347 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4348 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4349 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4350 return incompatTy;
4351 }
4352 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4353 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4354 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4355 return compositeType;
4356 }
4357 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4358 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4359 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4360 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4361 QualType destPointee
4362 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4363 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4364 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4365 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4366 // Promote to void*.
4367 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4368 return destType;
4369 }
4370 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4371 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4372 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4373 QualType destPointee
4374 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4375 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4376 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4377 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4378 // Promote to void*.
4379 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4380 return destType;
4381 }
4382 return QualType();
4383}
4384
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004385/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004386/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004387Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4388 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4389 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4390 ExprArg RHS) {
4391 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4392 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004393
4394 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4395 // was the condition.
4396 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4397 if (isLHSNull)
4398 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004399
4400 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004401 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004402 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004403 return ExprError();
4404
4405 Cond.release();
4406 LHS.release();
4407 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004408 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004409 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004410 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004411}
4412
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004413// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004414// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004415// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4416// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4417// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004418Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004419Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4420 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004421
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004422 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4423 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4424 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4425 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4426 return Compatible;
4427 }
4428
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004429 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004430 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4431 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004432
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004433 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004434 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4435 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004436
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004437 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004438
4439 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4440 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4441 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004442 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004443 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004444 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004445
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004446 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4447 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004448 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004449 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004450 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004451 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004452
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004453 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004454 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4455 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004456 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004457
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004458 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004459 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004460 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004461
4462 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004463 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4464 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004465 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004466 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004467 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004468 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4469 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4470 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4471 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4472 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4473 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004474 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004475 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004476 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004477 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004478
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004479 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004480 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004481 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004482 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004483
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004484 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4485 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4486 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4487 // warning can be disabled.
4488 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4489 return ConvTy;
4490 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4491 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004492
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004493 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4494 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4495 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4496 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4497 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4498 do {
4499 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4500 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004501
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004502 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4503 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4504 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004505
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004506 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004507 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004508 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004509
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004510 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004511 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004512 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004513 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004514}
4515
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004516/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4517/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4518/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4519// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004520Sema::AssignConvertType
4521Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004522 QualType rhsType) {
4523 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004524
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004525 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004526 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4527 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004528
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004529 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4530 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4531 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004532
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004533 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004534
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004535 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004536 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004537 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004538
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004539 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4540 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4541 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4542 }
4543 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004544 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004545 return ConvTy;
4546}
4547
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004548/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4549/// for assignment compatibility.
4550Sema::AssignConvertType
4551Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004552 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4553 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004554 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4555 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004556 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004557 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004558 }
4559 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4560 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004561 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4562 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004563 return IncompatiblePointer;
4564 return Compatible;
4565 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004566 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004567 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004568 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004569 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4570 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4571 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4572 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4573 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4574 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004575
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004576 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4577 return Compatible;
4578 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4579 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004580 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004581}
4582
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004583/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4584/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004585/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4586///
4587/// int a, *pint;
4588/// short *pshort;
4589/// struct foo *pfoo;
4590///
4591/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4592/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4593/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4594/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4595///
4596/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004597/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004598///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004599Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004600Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004601 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4602 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004603 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4604 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004605
4606 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004607 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004608
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004609 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4610 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4611 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4612 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4613 return Compatible;
4614 }
4615
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004616 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4617 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4618 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4619 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4620 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4621 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4622 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004623 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004624 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004625 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004626 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004627 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004628 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4629 // to the same ExtVector type.
4630 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4631 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4632 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004633 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004634 return Compatible;
4635 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004636
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004637 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004638 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004639 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004640 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004641 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4642 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004643 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004644 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004645 }
4646 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004647 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004648
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004649 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4650 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004651 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004652
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004653 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004654 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004655 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004656
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004657 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004658 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004659
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004660 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004661 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004662 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4663 return Compatible;
4664 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004665 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004666 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4667 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004668 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004669
4670 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004671 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004672 return Compatible;
4673 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004674 return Incompatible;
4675 }
4676
4677 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4678 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004679 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004680
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004681 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004682 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004683 return Compatible;
4684
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004685 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4686 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004687
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004688 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004689 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004690 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004691 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004692 return Incompatible;
4693 }
4694
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004695 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4696 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4697 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004698
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004699 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004700 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004701 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4702 return Compatible;
4703 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004704 }
4705 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004706 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004707 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004708 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004709 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4710 return Compatible;
4711 }
4712 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4713 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4714 return Compatible;
4715 return Incompatible;
4716 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004717 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004718 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004719 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4720 return Compatible;
4721
4722 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004723 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004724
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004725 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004726 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004727
4728 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004729 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004730 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004731 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004732 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004733 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4734 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4735 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4736 return Compatible;
4737
4738 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4739 return PointerToInt;
4740
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004741 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004742 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004743 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4744 return Compatible;
4745 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004746 }
4747 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004748 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004749 return Compatible;
4750 return Incompatible;
4751 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004752
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004753 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004754 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004755 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004756 }
4757 return Incompatible;
4758}
4759
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004760/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4761/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004762static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004763 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4764 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4765 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004766 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004767 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004768 SourceLocation());
4769 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4770 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4771
4772 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4773 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004774 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004775 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004776 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004777}
4778
4779Sema::AssignConvertType
4780Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4781 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4782
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004783 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004784 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4785 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004786 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004787 return Incompatible;
4788
4789 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4790 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4791 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4792 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004793 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4794 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004795 it != itend; ++it) {
4796 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4797 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4798 // 1) void pointer
4799 // 2) null pointer constant
4800 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004801 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004802 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004803 InitField = *it;
4804 break;
4805 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004806
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004807 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004808 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004809 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004810 InitField = *it;
4811 break;
4812 }
4813 }
4814
4815 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4816 == Compatible) {
4817 InitField = *it;
4818 break;
4819 }
4820 }
4821
4822 if (!InitField)
4823 return Incompatible;
4824
4825 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4826 return Compatible;
4827}
4828
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004829Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004830Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004831 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4832 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4833 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4834 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4835 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004836 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004837 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004838 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004839 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004840 }
4841
4842 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4843 // structures.
4844 }
4845
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004846 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4847 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004848 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4849 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004850 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004851 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004852 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004853 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004854 return Compatible;
4855 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004856
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004857 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004858 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004859 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004860 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004861 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004862 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004863 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004864 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004865
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004866 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4867 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004868
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004869 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4870 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004871 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4872 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4873 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4874 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004875 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004876 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4877 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004878 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004879}
4880
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004881QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004882 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004883 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004884 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004885 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004886}
4887
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004888QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004889 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004890 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004891 QualType lhsType =
4892 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4893 QualType rhsType =
4894 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004895
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004896 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004897 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004898 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004899
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004900 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4901 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004902 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4903 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004904 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4905 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004906 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004907 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004908 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4909 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4910 return lhsType;
4911 }
4912
4913 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4914 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004915 }
4916 }
4917 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004918
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004919 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4920 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4921 bool swapped = false;
4922 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4923 swapped = true;
4924 std::swap(rex, lex);
4925 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4926 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004927
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004928 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004929 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004930 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004931 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004932 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004933 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004934 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4935 return lhsType;
4936 }
4937 }
4938 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4939 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4940 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004941 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004942 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4943 return lhsType;
4944 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004945 }
4946 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004947
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004948 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004949 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004950 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004951 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004952 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004953}
4954
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004955QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4956 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004957 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004958 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004959
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004960 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004961
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004962 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4963 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4964 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004965
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004966 // Check for division by zero.
4967 if (isDiv &&
4968 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004969 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004970 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004971
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004972 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004973}
4974
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004975QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004976 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00004977 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4978 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4979 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4980 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
4981 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004982
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004983 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004984
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004985 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
4986 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004987
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004988 // Check for remainder by zero.
4989 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004990 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
4991 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004992
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004993 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004994}
4995
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004996QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004997 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00004998 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
4999 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5000 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5001 return compType;
5002 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005003
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005004 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005005
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005006 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005007 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5008 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5009 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005010 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005011 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005012
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005013 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5014 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005015 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005016 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5017
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005018 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005019
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005020 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005021 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005022
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005023 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5024 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005025 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5026 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005027 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005028 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005029 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005030
5031 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5032 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5033 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005034 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005035 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5036 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5037 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5038 return QualType();
5039 }
5040
5041 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5042 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5043 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005044 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005045 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005046 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005047 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005048 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5049 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005050 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5051 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005052 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005053 return QualType();
5054 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005055 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005056 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005057 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5058 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5059 return QualType();
5060 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005061
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005062 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005063 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5064 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5065 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5066 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5067 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005068 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005069 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5070 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005071 return PExp->getType();
5072 }
5073 }
5074
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005075 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005076}
5077
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005078// C99 6.5.6
5079QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005080 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5081 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5082 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5083 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5084 return compType;
5085 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005086
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005087 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005088
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005089 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005090
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005091 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005092 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5093 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005094 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005095 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005096 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005097
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005098 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005099 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005100 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005101
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005102 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005103
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005104 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5105 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5106 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5107 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5108 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5109 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5110 return QualType();
5111 }
5112
5113 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5114 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5115 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5116 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5117 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005118 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005119 return QualType();
5120 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005121
5122 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5123 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5124 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005125 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005126 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005127 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005128 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005129 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005130
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005131 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005132 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005133 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5134 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5135 return QualType();
5136 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005137
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005138 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005139 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5140 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5141 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5142 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5143 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5144 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005145 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005146 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5147
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005148 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005149 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005150 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005151
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005152 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005153 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005154 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005155
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005156 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5157 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5158 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5159 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5160 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5161 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5162 return QualType();
5163 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005164
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005165 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5166 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5167 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5168 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005169 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005170 return QualType();
5171 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005172
5173 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5174 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5175 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5176 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5177 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005178 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5179 << rex->getSourceRange()
5180 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005181 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005182
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005183 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5184 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5185 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5186 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5187 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5188 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5189 return QualType();
5190 }
5191 } else {
5192 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5193 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5194 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5195 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5196 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5197 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5198 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5199 return QualType();
5200 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005201 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005202
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005203 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5204 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5205 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5206 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5207 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005208 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005209 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005210
5211 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005212 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5213 }
5214 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005215
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005216 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005217}
5218
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005219// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005220QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005221 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005222 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5223 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005224 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005225
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005226 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5227 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5228 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5229
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005230 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5231 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005232 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5233 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5234 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5235 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5236 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005237 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005238 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005239 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005240
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005241 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005242
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005243 // Sanity-check shift operands
5244 llvm::APSInt Right;
5245 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005246 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5247 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005248 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005249 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5250 else {
5251 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5252 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5253 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5254 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5255 }
5256 }
5257
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005258 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005259 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005260}
5261
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005262// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005263QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005264 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5265 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5266
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005267 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005268 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005269 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005270
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005271 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5272 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005273
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005274 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5275 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005276 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5277 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5278 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005279 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenek9ecede72009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005280 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005281 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5282 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5283 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005284 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekb82dcd82009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005285 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005286 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl())) {
5287 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5288 << 0 // self-
5289 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5290 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5291 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5292 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5293 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5294 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5295 // what is it always going to eval to?
5296 char always_evals_to;
5297 switch(Opc) {
5298 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5299 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5300 break;
5301 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5302 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5303 break;
5304 default:
5305 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5306 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5307 break;
5308 }
5309 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5310 << 1 // array
5311 << always_evals_to);
5312 }
5313 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005314
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005315 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5316 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5317 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5318 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005319
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005320 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5321 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005322 Expr *literalString = 0;
5323 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005324 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005325 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005326 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005327 literalString = lex;
5328 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005329 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5330 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005331 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005332 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005333 literalString = rex;
5334 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5335 }
5336
5337 if (literalString) {
5338 std::string resultComparison;
5339 switch (Opc) {
5340 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5341 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5342 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5343 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5344 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5345 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5346 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5347 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005348
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005349 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5350 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5351 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005352 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005353 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005354 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005355
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005356 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5357 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5358 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5359 else {
5360 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5361 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5362 }
5363
5364 lType = lex->getType();
5365 rType = rex->getType();
5366
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005367 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005368 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005369
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005370 if (isRelational) {
5371 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005372 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005373 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005374 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005375 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005376 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005377
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005378 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005379 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005380 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005381
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005382 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005383 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005384 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005385 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005386
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005387 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5388 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005389 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005390 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005391 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005392 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005393 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005394
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005395 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005396 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5397 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005398 if (!isRelational &&
5399 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5400 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5401 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005402 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5403 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005404 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5405 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005406 Diag(Loc,
5407 isSFINAEContext()?
5408 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5409 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005410 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005411
5412 if (isSFINAEContext())
5413 return QualType();
5414
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005415 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5416 return ResultTy;
5417 }
5418 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005419 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5420 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5421 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5422 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5423 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5424 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005425 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005426 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005427 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005428 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005429 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005430 if (T.isNull()) {
5431 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5432 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5433 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005434 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005435 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005436 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005437 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005438 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005439 }
5440
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005441 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5442 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005443 return ResultTy;
5444 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005445 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5446 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5447 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5448 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5449 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5450 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5451 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5452 }
5453 } else if (!isRelational &&
5454 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5455 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5456 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5457 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5458 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5459 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5460 }
5461 } else {
5462 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005463 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005464 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005465 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005466 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005467 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005468 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005469 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005470
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005471 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005472 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005473 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005474 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005475 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5476 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005477 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005478 return ResultTy;
5479 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005480 if (LHSIsNull &&
5481 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5482 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005483 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005484 return ResultTy;
5485 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005486
5487 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005488 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005489 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5490 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005491 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5492 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5493 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5494 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5495 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5496 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5497 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5498 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005499 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005500 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005501 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005502 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005503 if (T.isNull()) {
5504 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005505 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005506 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005507 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005508 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005509 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005510 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005511 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005512 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005513
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005514 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5515 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005516 return ResultTy;
5517 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005518
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005519 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005520 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5521 return ResultTy;
5522 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005523
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005524 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005525 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005526 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5527 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005528
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005529 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005530 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005531 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005532 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005533 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005534 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005535 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005536 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005537 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005538 if (!isRelational
5539 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5540 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005541 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005542 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005543 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005544 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005545 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5546 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5547 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005548 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005549 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005550 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005551 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005552
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005553 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005554 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005555 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5556 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005557 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005558 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005559 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005560 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005561
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005562 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5563 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005564 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005565 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005566 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005567 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005568 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005569 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005570 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005571 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005572 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5573 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005574 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005575 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005576 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005577 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005578 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5579 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005580 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005581 bool isError = false;
5582 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5583 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5584 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005585 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005586 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005587 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005588 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5589 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5590 isError = true;
5591 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005592 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005593
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005594 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005595 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005596 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005597 if (isError)
5598 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005599 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005600
5601 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5602 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005603 else
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005604 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005605 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005606 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005607
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005608 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005609 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5610 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005611 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005612 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005613 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005614 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5615 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005616 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005617 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005618 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005619 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005620}
5621
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005622/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005623/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005624/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5625/// types.
5626QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005627 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005628 bool isRelational) {
5629 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5630 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005631 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005632 if (vType.isNull())
5633 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005634
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005635 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5636 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005637
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005638 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5639 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5640 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005641 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005642 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5643 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5644 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005645 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5646 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5647 << 0 // self-
5648 << 2 // "a constant"
5649 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005650 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005651
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005652 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005653 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5654 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005655 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005656 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005657
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005658 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5659 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5660 // elements for floating point vectors.
5661 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5662 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005663
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005664 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005665 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005666 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005667 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005668 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005669 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5670
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005671 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005672 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005673 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5674}
5675
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005676inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005677 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff3e5e5562007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005678 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005679 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005680
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005681 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005682
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005683 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005684 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005685 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005686}
5687
5688inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005689 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005690 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5691 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5692 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005693
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005694 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5695 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005696
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005697 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005698 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005699
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005700 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5701 // non-overloadable operands.
5702
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005703 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5704 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005705 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5706 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5707 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005708 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005709
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005710 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5711 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5712 // The result is a bool.
5713 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005714}
5715
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005716/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5717/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5718/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5719///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005720static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005721 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5722 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5723 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5724 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005725 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005726 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5727 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5728 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5729 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005730 }
5731 }
5732 return false;
5733}
5734
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005735/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5736/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5737static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005738 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005739 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005740 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005741 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5742 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005743 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5744 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005745
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005746 unsigned Diag = 0;
5747 bool NeedType = false;
5748 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005749 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005750 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005751 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5752 NeedType = true;
5753 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005754 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005755 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5756 NeedType = true;
5757 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005758 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005759 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5760 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005761 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5762 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005763 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005764 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5765 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005766 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5767 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005768 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5769 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005770 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005771 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005772 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005773 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005774 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5775 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005776 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005777 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5778 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005779 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5780 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5781 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005782 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5783 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5784 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005785 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5786 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5787 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005788 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005789
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005790 SourceRange Assign;
5791 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5792 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005793 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005794 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005795 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005796 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005797 return true;
5798}
5799
5800
5801
5802// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005803QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5804 SourceLocation Loc,
5805 QualType CompoundType) {
5806 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5807 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005808 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005809
5810 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5811 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005812 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005813 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005814 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005815 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005816 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5817 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5818 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5819 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5820 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5821 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5822 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5823 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5824 }
5825 }
5826
5827 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005828 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5829 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5830 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005831 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005832 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005833 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005834 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005835
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005836 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5837 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5838 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005839 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005840 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5841 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5842 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5843 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5844 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005845 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005846 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005847 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5848 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5849 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005850 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5851 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005852 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5853 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5854 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005855 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005856 }
5857 } else {
5858 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005859 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005860 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005861
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005862 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005863 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005864 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005865
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005866 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5867 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005868 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005869 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5870 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005871 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005872 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005873 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005874}
5875
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005876// C99 6.5.17
5877QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00005878 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
5879
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005880 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005881 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5882 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5883 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005884
5885 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5886 // incomplete in C++).
5887
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005888 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005889}
5890
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005891/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5892/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005893QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005894 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005895 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5896 return Context.DependentTy;
5897
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005898 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5899 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005900
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005901 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5902 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5903 if (!isInc) {
5904 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5905 return QualType();
5906 }
5907 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5908 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5909 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005910 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005911 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5912 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005913
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005914 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005915 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005916 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5917 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5918 << Op->getSourceRange();
5919 return QualType();
5920 }
5921
5922 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005923 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005924 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005925 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5926 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5927 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5928 return QualType();
5929 }
5930
5931 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005932 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005933 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005934 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005935 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005936 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005937 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005938 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005939 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005940 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5941 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5942 return QualType();
5943 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005944 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005945 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5946 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005947 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005948 } else {
5949 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005950 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005951 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005952 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005953 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005954 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005955 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005956 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005957 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5958 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5959 // operand.
5960 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5961 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005962}
5963
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005964/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005965/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005966/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5967/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5968/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5969/// - &(x) => x
5970/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5971/// - &s.xx => s
5972/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5973/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5974/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5975/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005976static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005977 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005978 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005979 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005980 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005981 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5982 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5983 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005984 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005985 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005986 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005987 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005988 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005989 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5990 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005991 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5992 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5993 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5994 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5995 }
5996 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005997 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005998 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5999 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006000
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006001 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006002 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6003 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6004 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6005 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6006 default:
6007 return 0;
6008 }
6009 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006010 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006011 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006012 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006013 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6014 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006015 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006016 default:
6017 return 0;
6018 }
6019}
6020
6021/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006022/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006023/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006024/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006025/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006026/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006027/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006028QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006029 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6030 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6031
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006032 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6033 return Context.DependentTy;
6034
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006035 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6036 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6037 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6038 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6039 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6040 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6041 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6042 }
6043 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6044 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6045 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006046 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006047 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006048
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006049 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6050 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6051 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6052 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6053 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6054 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6055 // branch of the if, below.
6056 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6057 << dcl;
6058 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6059
6060 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6061 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6062 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6063 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006064 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6065 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6066 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6067 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6068 if (isSFINAEContext())
6069 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian949bd4b2010-06-17 21:45:48 +00006070 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
6071 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006072 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006073 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006074 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006075 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006076 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006077 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6078 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006079 return QualType();
6080 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006081 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006082 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6083 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6084 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006085 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006086 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006087 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006088 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006089 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006090 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006091 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6092 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6093 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6094 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6095 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006096 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6097 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006098 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6099 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006100 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6101 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006102 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006103 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006104 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6105 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6106 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006107 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6108 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006109 return QualType();
6110 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006111 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006112 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006113 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006114 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006115 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6116 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006117 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006118 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006119 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6120 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006121 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006122 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6123 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6124 return QualType();
6125 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006126
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006127 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6128 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006129 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006130 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006131 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006132 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006133 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006134 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6135 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006136 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6137 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6138 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006139 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006140 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006141
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006142 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6143 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6144 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6145 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6146 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6147 }
6148
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006149 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
6150 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6151}
6152
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006153QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006154 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6155 return Context.DependentTy;
6156
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006157 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6158 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006159
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006160 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6161 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6162 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6163 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006164 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006165 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006166
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006167 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanian16b10372009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006168 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006169
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006170 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006171 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006172 return QualType();
6173}
6174
6175static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6176 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6177 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6178 switch (Kind) {
6179 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006180 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6181 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006182 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6183 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6184 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6185 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6186 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6187 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6188 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6189 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6190 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6191 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6192 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6193 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6194 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6195 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6196 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6197 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6198 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6199 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6200 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6201 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6202 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6203 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6204 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6205 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6206 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6207 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6208 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6209 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6210 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6211 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6212 }
6213 return Opc;
6214}
6215
6216static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6217 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6218 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6219 switch (Kind) {
6220 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6221 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6222 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6223 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6224 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6225 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6226 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6227 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6228 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006229 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6230 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6231 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6232 }
6233 return Opc;
6234}
6235
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006236/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6237/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6238/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006239Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6240 unsigned Op,
6241 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006242 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006243 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006244 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6245 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6246 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006247
6248 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006249 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6250 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6251 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006252 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6253 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6254 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6255 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6256 break;
6257 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006258 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006259 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6260 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006261 break;
6262 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6263 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6264 break;
6265 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6266 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6267 break;
6268 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6269 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6270 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006271 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006272 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6273 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6274 break;
6275 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6276 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6277 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6278 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006279 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006280 break;
6281 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6282 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006283 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006284 break;
6285 case BinaryOperator::And:
6286 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6287 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6288 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6289 break;
6290 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6291 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6292 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6293 break;
6294 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6295 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006296 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6297 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006298 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6299 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6300 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006301 break;
6302 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006303 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6304 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6305 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6306 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006307 break;
6308 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006309 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6310 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6311 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006312 break;
6313 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006314 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6315 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6316 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006317 break;
6318 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6319 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006320 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6321 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6322 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6323 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006324 break;
6325 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6326 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6327 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006328 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6329 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6330 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6331 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006332 break;
6333 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6334 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6335 break;
6336 }
6337 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006338 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006339 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006340 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6341 else
6342 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006343 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6344 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006345}
6346
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006347/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6348/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006349static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6350 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006351 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6352 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6353 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006354 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006355 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6356
6357 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6358 return;
6359
6360 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6361 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6362 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006363 return;
6364 }
6365
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006366 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6367 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006368 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006369
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006370 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006371 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006372
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006373 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6374 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6375 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6376 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006377 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006378 return;
6379 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006380
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006381 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006382 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6383 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006384}
6385
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006386/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6387/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6388/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6389/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006390static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6391 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006392 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6393 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6394 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6395 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006396 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006397 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006398 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6399
6400 // Subs are not binary operators.
6401 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6402 return;
6403
6404 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6405 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006406 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6407 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006408 return;
6409
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006410 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006411 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006412 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006413 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6414 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006415 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006416 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006417 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6418 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6419 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6420 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006421 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006422 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006423 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006424 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6425 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006426 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006427 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006428 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6429 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6430 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6431 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006432}
6433
6434/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6435/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6436/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6437static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6438 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006439 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006440 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6441}
6442
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006443// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006444Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6445 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6446 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006447 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006448 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006449
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006450 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6451 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006452
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006453 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6454 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6455
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006456 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6457}
6458
6459Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6460 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6461 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006462 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006463 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006464 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6465 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6466 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6467 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6468 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006469 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006470 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006471 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6472 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6473 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006474
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006475 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6476 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006477 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006478 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006479
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006480 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006481 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006482}
6483
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006484Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006485 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006486 ExprArg InputArg) {
6487 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006488
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006489 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006490 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006491 QualType resultType;
6492 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006493 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6494 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6495 break;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006496
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006497 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6498 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006499 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6500 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006501 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006502 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006503 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6504 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6505 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006506 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006507 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006508 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6509 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006510 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006511 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006512 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6513 break;
6514 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6515 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006516 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6517 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006518 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6519 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006520 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6521 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006522 break;
6523 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6524 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6525 break;
6526 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6527 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6528 resultType->isPointerType())
6529 break;
6530
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006531 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6532 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006533 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006534 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6535 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006536 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6537 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006538 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6539 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6540 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006541 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006542 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006543 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006544 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6545 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006546 break;
6547 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6548 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006549 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006550 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006551 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6552 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006553 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006554 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6555 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006556 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006557 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6558 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006559 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006560 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006561 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006562 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006563 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006564 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006565 resultType = Input->getType();
6566 break;
6567 }
6568 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006569 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006570
6571 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006572 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006573}
6574
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006575Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6576 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6577 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006578 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006579 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6580 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006581 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6582 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6583 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6584 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006585 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006586 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006587 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6588 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6589 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006590
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006591 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6592 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006593
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006594 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6595}
6596
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006597// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6598Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6599 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6600 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6601}
6602
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006603/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006604Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6605 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6606 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006607 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006608 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006609
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006610 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6611 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006612 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006613 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006614
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006615 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006616 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6617 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006618}
6619
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006620Sema::OwningExprResult
6621Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6622 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6623 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006624 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6625 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6626
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006627 bool isFileScope
6628 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006629 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006630 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006631
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006632 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6633 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6634 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006635
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006636 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6637 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6638 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006639
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006640 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6641 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6642 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6643 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6644 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006645
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006646 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006647 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006648 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006649
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006650 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6651 // expressions are not lvalues.
6652
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006653 substmt.release();
6654 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006655}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006656
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006657Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6658 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006659 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6660 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006661 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6662 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006663 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006664 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006665
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006666 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6667 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6668 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006669 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006670 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6671 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6672
6673 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6674 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6675 if (!Dependent
6676 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6677 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6678 << TypeRange))
6679 return ExprError();
6680
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006681 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6682 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006683 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6684 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006685 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006686 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6687 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006688
6689 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6690 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6691 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6692 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6693 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6694 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6695 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6696 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6697 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6698 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6699 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6700 if(!AT)
6701 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6702 << CurrentType);
6703 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6704 } else
6705 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6706
6707 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6708 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6709 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6710 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6711 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6712 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6713 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6714 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6715
6716 // Record this array index.
6717 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6718 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6719 continue;
6720 }
6721
6722 // Offset of a field.
6723 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6724 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6725 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6726 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6727 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6728 continue;
6729 }
6730
6731 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6732 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6733 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6734 return ExprError();
6735
6736 // Look for the designated field.
6737 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6738 if (!RC)
6739 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6740 << CurrentType);
6741 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6742
6743 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6744 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6745 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6746 // (clause 9).
6747 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6748 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6749 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6750 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6751 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6752 << CurrentType))
6753 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6754 }
6755
6756 // Look for the field.
6757 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6758 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6759 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6760 if (!MemberDecl)
6761 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6762 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6763 OC.LocEnd));
6764
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006765 // C99 7.17p3:
6766 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6767 //
6768 // We diagnose this as an error.
6769 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6770 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6771 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6772 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6773 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6774 return ExprError();
6775 }
6776
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006777 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6778 // the base class indirections.
6779 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6780 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6781 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6782 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6783 Paths)) {
6784 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6785 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6786 B != BEnd; ++B)
6787 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6788 }
6789
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006790 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006791 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006792 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6793 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6794 unsigned n = Path.size();
6795 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6796 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6797 } else {
6798 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6799 }
6800 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6801 }
6802
6803 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6804 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6805 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6806}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006807
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006808Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6809 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6810 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6811 TypeTy *argty,
6812 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6813 unsigned NumComponents,
6814 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6815
6816 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6817 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6818 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6819 return ExprError();
6820
6821 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6822 if (!ArgTInfo)
6823 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6824
6825 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6826 RPLoc);
6827 }
6828
6829 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6830 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6831
6832 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6833
6834 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6835 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6836 // a struct/union/class.
6837 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6838 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6839
6840 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6841 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6842
6843 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6844 // the offsetof designators.
6845 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6846 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6847 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6848 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6849
6850 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6851 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6852 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6853 // a system header!
6854 if (NumComponents != 1)
6855 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6856 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6857
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006858 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedmanc0d600c2009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006859 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006860
John McCalld00f2002009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006861 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6862 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6863 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006864
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006865 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6866 // leaks like a sieve.
6867 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6868 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6869 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6870 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6871 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6872 if (!AT) {
6873 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006874 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006875 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006876 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006877
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006878 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006879
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006880 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6881 // expression.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006882 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006883
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006884 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6885 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006886 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006887 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006888 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006889 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006890 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6891
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006892 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6893 OC.LocEnd);
6894 continue;
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006895 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006896
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006897 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006898 if (!RC) {
6899 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006900 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006901 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006902 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006903
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006904 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6905 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006906 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006907 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6908 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6909 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006910 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6911 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006912 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006913 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006914
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006915 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6916 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006917
John McCall1bcee0a2009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006918 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006919 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006920 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregor3f093272009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006921 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006922 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6923
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006924 // C99 7.17p3:
6925 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6926 //
6927 // We diagnose this as an error.
6928 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6929 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6930 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6931 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6932 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6933 return ExprError();
6934 }
6935
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006936 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6937 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006938 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006939 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006940 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006941 } else {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006942 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6943 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006944 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6945 // doesn't matter here.
6946 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006947 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006948 }
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006949 }
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006950 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006951
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006952 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6953 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006954}
6955
6956
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006957Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6958 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6959 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006960 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6961 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6962 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006963
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006964 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006965
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006966 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6967 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6968 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6969 return ExprError();
6970 }
6971
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006972 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6973 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006974}
6975
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006976Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6977 ExprArg cond,
6978 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6979 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6980 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6981 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6982 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006983
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006984 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6985
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006986 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006987 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006988 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006989 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006990 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006991 } else {
6992 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6993 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6994 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6995 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006996 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6997 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6998 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006999
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007000 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7001 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007002 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7003 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007004 }
7005
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007006 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7007 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007008 resType, RPLoc,
7009 resType->isDependentType(),
7010 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007011}
7012
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007013//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7014// Clang Extensions.
7015//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7016
7017/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007018void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007019 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7020 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7021 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7022 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007023}
7024
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007025void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007026 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007027 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007028
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007029 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007030 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007031 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007032
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007033 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007034 QualType RetTy;
7035 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007036 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007037 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007038 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007039 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7040 } else {
7041 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007042 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007043 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007044
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007045 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007046
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007047 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7048 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7049 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007050 return;
7051 }
7052
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007053 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7054 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7055 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7056 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7057 return;
7058 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007059
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007060 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007061 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7062 // ^ * { ... }
7063 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007064 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7065 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007066
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007067 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007068 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007069 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7070 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7071 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7072 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007073 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7074 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7075 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7076 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7077 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007078 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007079 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007080
7081 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7082 // ^ fntype { ... }
7083 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7084 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7085 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7086 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7087 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7088 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7089 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007090 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007091 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007092 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007093
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007094 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7095 if (!Params.empty())
7096 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007097
7098 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007099 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007100
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007101 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007102 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7103 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7104 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7105 }
7106
7107 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7108 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007109 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007110 return;
7111
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007112 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7113 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7114
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007115 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007116 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7117 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7118
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007119 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007120 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7121 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7122 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7123
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007124 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007125 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007126 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007127}
7128
7129/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7130/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7131void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007132 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007133 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007134 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007135 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007136}
7137
7138/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7139/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007140Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7141 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007142 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7143 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7144 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007145
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007146 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007147
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007148 PopDeclContext();
7149
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007150 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007151 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7152 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007153
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007154 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007155 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007156
7157 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7158 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7159 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7160
7161 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7162 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7163
7164 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7165 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7166 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7167 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7168
7169 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7170 // preserve its sugar structure.
7171 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7172 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7173 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7174
7175 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7176 } else {
7177 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7178 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7179 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7180 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7181 FPT->isVariadic(),
7182 /*quals*/ 0,
7183 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7184 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7185 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7186 FPT->exception_begin(),
7187 Ext);
7188 }
7189
7190 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7191 } else {
7192 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7193 false, false, 0, 0,
7194 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7195 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007196
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007197 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007198 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7199 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007200 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007201
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007202 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007203 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007204 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007205
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007206 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007207
7208 bool Good = true;
7209 // Check goto/label use.
7210 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7211 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7212 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7213
7214 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7215 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7216 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7217 continue;
7218
7219 // Emit error.
7220 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7221 Good = false;
7222 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007223 if (!Good) {
7224 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007225 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007226 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007227
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007228 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007229 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7230 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7231 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007232
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007233 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7234 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007235 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007236 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007237}
7238
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007239Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7240 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7241 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007242 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007243 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7244 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007245
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007246 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007247
7248 // Get the va_list type
7249 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007250 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7251 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7252 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7253 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007254 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007255 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7256 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7257 } else {
7258 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7259 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007260 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007261 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007262 return ExprError();
7263 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007264
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007265 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7266 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007267 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7268 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007269 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007270 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007271
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007272 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007273 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007274
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007275 expr.release();
7276 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7277 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007278}
7279
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007280Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007281 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7282 // pointers on the target.
7283 QualType Ty;
7284 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7285 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7286 else
7287 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7288
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007289 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007290}
7291
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007292static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007293 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007294 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7295 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007296
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007297 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7298 if (!PT)
7299 return;
7300
7301 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7302 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7303 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7304 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7305 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7306 return;
7307 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007308
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007309 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7310 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7311 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7312 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007313
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007314 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007315}
7316
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007317bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7318 SourceLocation Loc,
7319 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007320 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7321 bool *Complained) {
7322 if (Complained)
7323 *Complained = false;
7324
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007325 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7326 bool isInvalid = false;
7327 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007328 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007329
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007330 switch (ConvTy) {
7331 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7332 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007333 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007334 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7335 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007336 case IntToPointer:
7337 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7338 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007339 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007340 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007341 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7342 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007343 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7344 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7345 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007346 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7347 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7348 break;
7349 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007350 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7351 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7352 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7353 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7354 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7355 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7356 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7357 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7358 // C++ semantics.
7359 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7360 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7361 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007362 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7363 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007364 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007365 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007366 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007367 case IntToBlockPointer:
7368 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7369 break;
7370 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007371 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007372 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007373 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007374 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007375 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7376 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7377 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007378 case IncompatibleVectors:
7379 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7380 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007381 case Incompatible:
7382 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7383 isInvalid = true;
7384 break;
7385 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007386
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007387 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7388 switch (Action) {
7389 case AA_Assigning:
7390 case AA_Initializing:
7391 // The destination type comes first.
7392 FirstType = DstType;
7393 SecondType = SrcType;
7394 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007395
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007396 case AA_Returning:
7397 case AA_Passing:
7398 case AA_Converting:
7399 case AA_Sending:
7400 case AA_Casting:
7401 // The source type comes first.
7402 FirstType = SrcType;
7403 SecondType = DstType;
7404 break;
7405 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007406
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007407 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007408 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007409 if (Complained)
7410 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007411 return isInvalid;
7412}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007413
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007414bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007415 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7416 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7417 if (Result)
7418 *Result = ICEResult;
7419 return false;
7420 }
7421
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007422 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7423
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007424 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007425 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7426 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7427
7428 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7429 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7430 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7431 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7432 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7433 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7434 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007435
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007436 return true;
7437 }
7438
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007439 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7440 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007441
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007442 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7443 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7444 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007445
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007446 if (Result)
7447 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7448 return false;
7449}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007450
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007451void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007452Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007453 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7454 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007455}
7456
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007457void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007458Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7459 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7460 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7461 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007462
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007463 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7464 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7465 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7466 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7467 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007468 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007469 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7470 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7471 I != IEnd; ++I)
7472 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7473 }
7474
7475 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7476 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7477 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7478 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7479 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7480 I != IEnd; ++I)
7481 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7482 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007483 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007484
7485 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7486 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7487 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7488 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007489 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007490 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7491 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7492 ExprTemporaries.end());
7493
7494 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7495 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007496}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007497
7498/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7499///
7500/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7501/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7502/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7503/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7504///
7505/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7506///
7507/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7508void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7509 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007510
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007511 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007512 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007513
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007514 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7515 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7516 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7517 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007518 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007519 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007520 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007521 return;
7522 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007523
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007524 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7525 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007526
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007527 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7528 // an instantiation.
7529 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7530 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007531
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007532 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007533 case Unevaluated:
7534 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7535 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007536
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007537 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7538 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7539 // "used"; handle this below.
7540 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007541
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007542 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7543 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7544 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7545 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007546 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007547 return;
7548 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007549
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007550 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007551 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007552 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007553 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007554 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007555 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007556 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007557 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007558 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007559 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7560 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007561
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007562 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007563 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007564 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007565 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007566 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7567 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007568 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7569 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7570 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007571 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007572 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007573 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7574 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007575 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007576 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007577 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007578 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007579 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007580 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7581 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7582 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7583 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7584 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007585 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007586 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007587 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007588 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007589 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7590 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7591 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007592 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007593 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007594 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7595 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007596
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007597 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7598 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7599 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7600 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7601 Loc));
7602 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007603 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007604 Loc));
7605 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007606 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007607
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007608 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007609 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007610
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007611 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007612 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007613
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007614 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007615 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007616 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007617 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7618 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7619 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7620 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7621 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7622 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7623 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7624 }
7625 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007626
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007627 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007628
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007629 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007630 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007631 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007632}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007633
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007634namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007635 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007636 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007637 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007638 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7639 Sema &S;
7640 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007641
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007642 public:
7643 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007644
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007645 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007646
7647 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7648 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007649 };
7650}
7651
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007652bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7653 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007654 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7655 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7656 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007657
7658 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007659}
7660
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007661bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007662 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7663 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7664 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007665 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7666 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007667 }
7668
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007669 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007670}
7671
7672void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7673 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007674 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007675}
7676
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007677/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7678/// of the program being compiled.
7679///
7680/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007681/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007682/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7683/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7684/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7685/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007686/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007687/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007688///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007689/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7690/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7691/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7692/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007693bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007694 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7695 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7696 case Unevaluated:
7697 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7698 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007699
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007700 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7701 Diag(Loc, PD);
7702 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007703
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007704 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7705 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7706 break;
7707 }
7708
7709 return false;
7710}
7711
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007712bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7713 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7714 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7715 return false;
7716
7717 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7718 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7719 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7720 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007721
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007722 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007723 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007724 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7725 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007726 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007727 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7728 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7729 return true;
7730
7731 return false;
7732}
7733
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007734// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7735// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7736void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7737 SourceLocation Loc;
7738
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007739 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7740
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007741 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7742 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7743 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7744 return;
7745
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007746 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7747 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7748 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7749 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7750
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007751 // self = [<foo> init...]
7752 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7753 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7754 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7755
7756 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7757 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7758 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7759 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7760 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007761
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007762 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7763 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7764 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7765 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7766 return;
7767
7768 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7769 } else {
7770 // Not an assignment.
7771 return;
7772 }
7773
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007774 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007775 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007776
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007777 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007778 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007779 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007780 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7781 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7782 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007783}
7784
7785bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7786 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7787
7788 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007789 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007790
7791 QualType T = E->getType();
7792
7793 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7794 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7795 return true;
7796 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7797 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7798 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7799 return true;
7800 }
7801 }
7802
7803 return false;
7804}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007805
7806Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7807 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007808 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7809 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007810 return ExprError();
7811
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007812 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7813 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7814 return ExprError();
7815 }
7816
7817 return Owned(Sub);
7818}